blob: 609465c50523d58924cffcab46829758d583a901 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000100 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000101}
102
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000103/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000104/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000105/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
106///
107void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000109 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000110 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000111 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000112
113 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
114 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
116 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000117
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000118 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
119 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000120 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000121 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
122 int isMethod = 0;
123 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
124 // skip over named parameters.
125 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
126 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
127 if (nullPos)
128 --nullPos;
129 else
130 ++i;
131 }
132 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
133 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000134 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000135 // skip over named parameters.
136 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
137 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
138 if (nullPos)
139 --nullPos;
140 else
141 ++i;
142 }
143 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000145 // block or function pointer call.
146 QualType Ty = V->getType();
147 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000148 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000149 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
150 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000151 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
152 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
153 unsigned k;
154 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
155 if (nullPos)
156 --nullPos;
157 else
158 ++i;
159 }
160 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
161 }
162 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
163 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000164 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000165 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000166 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000167 return;
168
169 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000170 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000172 return;
173 }
174 int sentinel = i;
175 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
176 --sentinelPos;
177 ++i;
178 }
179 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
180 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000181 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000182 return;
183 }
184 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
185 ++i;
186 ++sentinel;
187 }
188 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000189 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
190 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
191 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000192 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
194 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
195 return;
196
197 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
198 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
199
200 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
201 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000202}
203
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000204SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
205 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
206 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
207}
208
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000209//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
210// Standard Promotions and Conversions
211//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
212
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
214void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
215 QualType Ty = E->getType();
216 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
217
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000218 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000219 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000220 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000221 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
222 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
223 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
224 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
225 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
226 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
227 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000228 //
229 // C++ 4.2p1:
230 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
231 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
232 //
233 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
234 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000235 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000236 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000237 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000238}
239
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000240void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
241 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000242
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000243 QualType Ty = E->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
245 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
246 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
247 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
248 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
249 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
250 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
251 // rvalue is T
252 //
253 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000254 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
255 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000256 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000257 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000258 }
259}
260
261
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000262/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000263/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000264/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
265/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
266/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
267Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
268 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
269 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000270
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000271 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
272 //
273 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
274 // unsigned int may be used:
275 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
276 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
277 // and unsigned int.
278 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
279 //
280 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
281 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
282 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
283 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000284 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
285 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000286 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000287 return Expr;
288 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000289 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000290 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000291 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000292 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000293 }
294
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000295 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000296 return Expr;
297}
298
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000299/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000300/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000301/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
302void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
303 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
304 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000305
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000306 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000307 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
308 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000309 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000310
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000311 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
312}
313
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
315/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
316/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
317/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000318bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
319 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000320 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000322 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
323 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
324 // etc.
325 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
326 return false;
327
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000328 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000329 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
330 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
331 << Expr->getType() << CT))
332 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000333
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000334 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000335 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000336 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
337 << Expr->getType() << CT))
338 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000339
340 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000341}
342
343
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000344/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
345/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000346/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000347/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
348/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
349/// GCC.
350QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
351 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000352 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000353 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000354
355 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000356
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000357 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000358 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000359 QualType lhs =
360 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000361 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000362 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363
364 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
365 if (lhs == rhs)
366 return lhs;
367
368 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
369 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
370 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
371 return lhs;
372
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000373 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000374 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000375 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
376 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000377 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000378 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
379 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
380
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000381 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000382 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000383 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
384 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000385 return destType;
386}
387
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000388//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
389// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
390//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
391
392
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000393/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000394/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
395/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
396/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
397/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000398///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000399ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000400Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000401 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
402
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000403 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000404 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000405 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000406
407 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
408 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
409 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000410
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000411 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000412 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000413 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000414
415 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000416 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000417 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000418
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000419 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
420 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
421 // strings.
422 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000423 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000424 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000425
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000426 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000427 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
428 Literal.GetStringLength(),
429 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
430 &StringTokLocs[0],
431 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000432}
433
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000434/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
435/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
436/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
437/// for values inside the block or for globals).
438///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000439/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000440/// up-to-date.
441///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000443 ValueDecl *VD) {
444 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
445 // we wanted to.
446 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
447 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000448
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000449 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
450 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
451 return false;
452
453 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
454 // snapshot it.
455 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
456 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000457 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
458 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000460 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
461 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
462
463 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
464 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
465 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
466 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000467 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
468 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000469
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000470 if (!NextBlock)
471 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000472
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000473 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
474 // having a reference outside it.
475 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
476 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000477
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000478 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
479 // a snapshot as well.
480 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
481 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000483 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484}
485
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000486
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000487ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000488Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000489 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000490 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
491 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
492}
493
494/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000495ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000496Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
497 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
498 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000499 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000501 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000502 << D->getDeclName();
503 return ExprError();
504 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000506 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000507 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
508 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
509 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000510 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000511 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000512 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
513 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000514 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
515 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000516 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000517 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000518 << D->getIdentifier();
519 return ExprError();
520 }
521 }
522 }
523 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000524
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000525 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000526
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000527 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
528 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
529 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000530 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000531}
532
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
534/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
535/// actual member.
536///
537/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
538/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
539/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
540/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
541/// we found.
542///
543/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
544/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
545/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
546VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
547 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
549 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
550 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
551
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000552 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
554 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
555 do {
556 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000557 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000558 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000559 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000560 else {
561 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
562 break;
563 }
564 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000565 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000566 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000567
568 return BaseObject;
569}
570
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000571ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000572Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
573 FieldDecl *Field,
574 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
575 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
576 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000577 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000578 AnonFields);
579
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
581 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
582 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
583 // found via name lookup.
584 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000585 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000586 if (BaseObject) {
587 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
588 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000589 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000590 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patela2c21a22010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000591 Loc);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000592 BaseQuals
593 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000594 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
595 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
596 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
597 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
598 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000599 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000600 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
601 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
602 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000603 BaseQuals
604 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 } else {
606 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
607 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
608 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000609 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
610 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000611 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000612 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 = Context.getTagDeclType(
614 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
615 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000616 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
618 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
619 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000620 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000621 MD->getThisType(Context),
622 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000623 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
624 }
625 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000626 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
627 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000628 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000629 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000630 }
631
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000632 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000633 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
634 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 }
636
637 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
638 // anonymous struct/union.
639 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000640 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000641 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
642 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
643 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
644 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000645 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
646 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
647
648 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
649 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
650 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
651 ResultQuals.removeConst();
652
653 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
654 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
655
656 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
657 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
658
659 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
660 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
661 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
662
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000663 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000664 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000665 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000666 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
667 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000668 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000669 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000670 }
671
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000672 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000673}
674
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000675/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000676/// possibly a list of template arguments.
677///
678/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
679/// DecomposeTemplateName.
680///
681/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
682/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
683/// some way.
684static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
685 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
686 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000687 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000688 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
689 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
690 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
691 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
692
693 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
694 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
695 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
696 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
697 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
698
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000699 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000700 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
701 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000702 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
703 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000704 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 TemplateArgs = 0;
706 }
707}
708
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000709/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
710/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
711/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000712static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000713 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
714 return false;
715
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000716 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
717 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
718 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
719 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
720 if (!BaseRT) return false;
721
722 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000723 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000724 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
725 return false;
726 }
727
728 return true;
729}
730
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
732/// the prospective base classes.
733static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
734 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
735 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000736 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000737 return false;
738
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000739 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000740 if (!RD) return false;
741 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
742
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000743 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
744 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
745 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
746 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
747 if (!BaseRT) return false;
748
749 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000750 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
751 return false;
752 }
753
754 return true;
755}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000756
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000757enum IMAKind {
758 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
759 IMA_Static,
760
761 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
762 IMA_Mixed,
763
764 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
765 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
766 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
767
768 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
769 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
770 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
771
772 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
773 IMA_Instance,
774
775 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
776 IMA_Unresolved,
777
778 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
779 /// context is not an instance method.
780 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
781
782 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
783 /// non-class context.
784 IMA_AnonymousMember,
785
786 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
789
790 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
791 /// class.
792 IMA_Error_Unrelated
793};
794
795/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
796/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
797/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
798/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
799/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
800/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
801static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
802 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000803 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000804
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000805 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000806 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000807 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
808 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000809
810 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
811 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
812
813 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
814 bool hasNonInstance = false;
815 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
816 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000817 NamedDecl *D = *I;
818 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000819 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
820
821 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
822 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
823 // that's a special case.
824 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
825 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
826 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
827 }
828 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
829 }
830 else
831 hasNonInstance = true;
832 }
833
834 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
835 // member reference.
836 if (Classes.empty())
837 return IMA_Static;
838
839 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
840 // an implicit member reference.
841 if (isStaticContext)
842 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
843
844 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
845 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
846 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
847 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000848 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000849 Classes))
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
851
852 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
853}
854
855/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
856static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
857 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
858 const LookupResult &R) {
859 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
860 SourceRange Range(Loc);
861 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
862
863 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
864 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
865 if (MD->isStatic()) {
866 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
867 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
868 << Range << R.getLookupName();
869 return;
870 }
871 }
872
873 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
874 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
875 return;
876 }
877
878 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000879}
880
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
882///
883/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000884bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
885 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000886 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
887
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000888 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000889 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000890 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
891 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000892 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000893 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000894 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
895 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
898 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
899 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
900 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000901 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000903 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
904 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
905
906 if (!R.empty()) {
907 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
908 R.suppressDiagnostics();
909
910 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
911 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
912 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
913 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
914
915 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
916 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
917 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000918 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000919 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
920 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000921 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000922 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000923 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000924 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
925 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
926 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
927 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
928 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
929 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
930 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
931 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
932 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
933 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
934 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
935 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
936 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
937 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000938 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000939 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
940 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
941 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000942 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000943 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000944 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000945 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000946
947 // Do we really want to note all of these?
948 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
949 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
950
951 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
952 return false;
953 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000954
955 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000956 }
957 }
958
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000959 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000960 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000961 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000962 if (!R.empty()) {
963 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
964 if (SS.isEmpty())
965 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
966 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
967 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
968 else
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
970 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
971 << SS.getRange()
972 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
973 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
974 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
975 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
976 << ND->getDeclName();
977
978 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
979 return false;
980 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000981
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000982 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
983 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
984 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
985 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
986 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
987 // to recover well anyway.
988 if (SS.isEmpty())
989 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
990 else
991 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
992 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
993 << SS.getRange();
994
995 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
996 return true;
997 }
998 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000999 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001000 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001001 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001002 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001003 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001004 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001005 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1006 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001007 return true;
1008 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001009 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001010 }
1011
1012 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1013 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1014 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1015 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1016 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1017 << SS.getRange();
1018 return true;
1019 }
1020
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001021 // Give up, we can't recover.
1022 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1023 return true;
1024}
1025
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001026static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001027 IdentifierInfo *II,
1028 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001029 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1030 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1031 if (!IDecl)
1032 return 0;
1033 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1034 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1035 return 0;
1036 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1037 if (!property)
1038 return 0;
1039 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1040 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1041 return 0;
1042 return property;
1043}
1044
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001045static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001046 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001047 IdentifierInfo *II,
1048 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1049 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001050 bool LookForIvars;
1051 if (Lookup.empty())
1052 LookForIvars = true;
1053 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1054 LookForIvars = false;
1055 else
1056 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1057 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1058 if (!LookForIvars)
1059 return 0;
1060
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001061 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1062 if (!IDecl)
1063 return 0;
1064 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001065 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1066 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001067 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1068 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1069 if (!property)
1070 return 0;
1071 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1072 DynamicImplSeen =
1073 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1074 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001075 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1076 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001077 NameLoc,
1078 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1079 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1080 (Expr *)0, true);
1081 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1082 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1083 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1084 return Ivar;
1085 }
1086 return 0;
1087}
1088
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001089ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001090 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1091 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1092 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1093 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001094 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1095 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1096
1097 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001098 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001099
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001100 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001101
1102 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001103 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001104 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001105 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001106
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001107 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001108 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001109 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001110
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001111 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1112 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001113 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1114 // (note: handled after lookup)
1115 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1116 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1117 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001118 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1119 // names a dependent type.
1120 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1121 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001122 bool DependentID = false;
1123 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1124 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1125 DependentID = true;
1126 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1127 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1128 if (DC) {
1129 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1130 return ExprError();
1131 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1132 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1133 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1134 } else {
1135 DependentID = true;
1136 }
1137 }
1138
1139 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001140 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 TemplateArgs);
1142 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001143 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001145 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001146 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001147 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1148 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1149 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1150 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1151 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001152 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1153 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1154 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001155 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001156 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001157 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001158
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001159 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1160 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001161 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001162 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 if (E.isInvalid())
1164 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001165
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1167 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001168 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1169 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001170 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001171 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1172 isAddressOfOperand);
1173 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001174 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1175 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001176 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001177 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001178
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001179 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1180 return ExprError();
1181
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001182 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1183 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001184 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001185
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001186 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001187 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001188 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1189 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1190 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1191 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1192 }
1193
1194 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1195 // call, diagnose the problem.
1196 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001197 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001198 return ExprError();
1199
1200 assert(!R.empty() &&
1201 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001202
1203 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1204 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001205 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001206 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1207 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001208 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001209 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1210 return move(E);
1211 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001212 }
1213 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001214
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1216 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1217
1218 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001219 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001220 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1221 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001222 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1223 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1224 if (Property) {
1225 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1226 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001227 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001228 }
1229 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001230 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001231 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1232 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1233 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1234 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1235 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1236 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001237 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001238 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001239
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001240 QualType T = Func->getType();
1241 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001242 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001243 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1244 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001245 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001246 }
1247 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001248
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001249 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001250 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1251 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1252 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1253 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1254 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1255 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1256 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1257 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001258 //
1259 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1260 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1261 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1262 // non-static member function:
1263 //
1264 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1265 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1266 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1267 // member function call.
1268 //
1269 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1270 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1271 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1272 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001273 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001274 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1275 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1276 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1277 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1278 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1279 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1280 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001281 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1282 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001283 else
1284 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1285
1286 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001287 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001288 }
1289
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001290 if (TemplateArgs)
1291 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001292
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001293 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1294}
1295
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001296/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001297ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001298Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1299 LookupResult &R,
1300 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1301 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1302 case IMA_Instance:
1303 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1304
1305 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1306 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1307 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1308 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1309
1310 case IMA_Mixed:
1311 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1312 case IMA_Unresolved:
1313 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1314
1315 case IMA_Static:
1316 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1317 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1318 if (TemplateArgs)
1319 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1320 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1321
1322 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1323 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1324 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1325 return ExprError();
1326 }
1327
1328 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1329 return ExprError();
1330}
1331
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001332/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1333/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1334/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1335/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001336ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001337Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001338 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001339 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001340 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001341 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001342
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001343 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001344 return ExprError();
1345
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001346 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001347 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1348
1349 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1350 return ExprError();
1351
1352 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001353 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1354 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001355 return ExprError();
1356 }
1357
1358 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1359}
1360
1361/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1362/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1363/// additional lookup.
1364///
1365/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1366/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1367///
1368/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001369ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001370Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001371 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001372 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001373 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001374
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1376 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1377 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1378 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1379 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1380
1381 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1382 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1383 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001384 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001385
1386 bool LookForIvars;
1387 if (Lookup.empty())
1388 LookForIvars = true;
1389 else if (IsClassMethod)
1390 LookForIvars = false;
1391 else
1392 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1393 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001394 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001395 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001396 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001397 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1398 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1399 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1400 if (IsClassMethod)
1401 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1402 << IV->getDeclName());
1403
1404 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1405 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1406 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1407 return ExprError();
1408
1409 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1410 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1411 return ExprError();
1412
1413 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1414 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1415 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1416 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1417
1418 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1419 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1420 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1421 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001422 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001423 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001424 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001425 SelfName, false, false);
1426 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1427 return ExprError();
1428
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001429 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1430 return Owned(new (Context)
1431 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1432 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1433 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001434 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001435 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001436 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001437 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1438 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1439 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1440 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1441 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1442 }
1443 }
1444
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001445 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1446 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1447 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1448 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1449 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1450 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1451 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1452 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1453 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1454 }
1455 }
1456 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001457 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1458 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001459}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001460
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001461/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1462///
1463/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1464///
1465/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1466/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1467/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1468/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1469///
1470/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1471/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1472/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1473/// the class declaring the member.
1474///
1475/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1476/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1477/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001478bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001479Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1480 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001481 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001482 NamedDecl *Member) {
1483 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1484 if (!RD)
1485 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001486
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001487 QualType DestRecordType;
1488 QualType DestType;
1489 QualType FromRecordType;
1490 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1491 bool PointerConversions = false;
1492 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1493 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001494
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001495 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1496 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1497 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1498 PointerConversions = true;
1499 } else {
1500 DestType = DestRecordType;
1501 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001502 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001503 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1504 if (Method->isStatic())
1505 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001506
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1508 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001509
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001510 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1511 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1512 PointerConversions = true;
1513 } else {
1514 FromRecordType = FromType;
1515 DestType = DestRecordType;
1516 }
1517 } else {
1518 // No conversion necessary.
1519 return false;
1520 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001521
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001522 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1523 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001524
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001525 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1526 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1527 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001528
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001529 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1530 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1531
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001532 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001533
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001534 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001535 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001536 // class name.
1537 //
1538 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1539 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1540 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1541 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1542 //
1543 // class Base { public: int x; };
1544 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1545 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1546 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1547 //
1548 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1549 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1550 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1551 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001552 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001553 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1554 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1555 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1556
1557 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1558
1559 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1560 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1561 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1562 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001563 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001564 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001565 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001566 return true;
1567
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001568 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001569 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001570 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1571 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001572
1573 FromType = QType;
1574 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1575
1576 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1577 // we're done.
1578 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1579 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001580 }
1581 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001582
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001583 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001584
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001585 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1586 // down to the using declaration's type.
1587 //
1588 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1589 // class ever has member declarations.
1590 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1591 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1592 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1593 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1594
1595 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1596 // conversion is non-trivial.
1597 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1598 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001599 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001600 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001601 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001602 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001603
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001604 QualType UType = URecordType;
1605 if (PointerConversions)
1606 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001607 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001608 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001609 FromType = UType;
1610 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1611 }
1612
1613 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1614 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1615 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001616 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001617
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001618 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001619 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1620 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001621 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001622 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001623
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001624 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001625 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001626 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001627}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001628
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001629/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001630static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001631 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001632 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001633 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1634 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001635 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1636 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1637 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001638 if (SS.isSet()) {
1639 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1640 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001641 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001642
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001644 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1645 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001646}
1647
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001648/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1649/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1650/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1651/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001652ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001653Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1654 LookupResult &R,
1655 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1656 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001657 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1658
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001659 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001660
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001661 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1662 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001663 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001664 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001665 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001666 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001667 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001668
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001669 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1670 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001671 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1672 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001673 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1674 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001675 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1676 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1677 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1678 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001679 }
1680
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001681 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001682 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1683 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001684 SS,
1685 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1686 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001687}
1688
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001689bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001690 const LookupResult &R,
1691 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001692 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1693 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1694 return false;
1695
1696 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001697 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001698 return false;
1699
1700 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001701 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001702 return false;
1703
1704 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1705 // normal lookup:
1706 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1707 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1708
1709 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1710 // -- a declaration of a class member
1711 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1712 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001713 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001714 return false;
1715
1716 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1717 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1718 // using-declaration
1719 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1720 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1721 // turn off ADL anyway).
1722 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1723 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1724 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1725 return false;
1726
1727 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1728 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1729 // template
1730 // And also for builtin functions.
1731 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1732 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1733
1734 // But also builtin functions.
1735 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1736 return false;
1737 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1738 return false;
1739 }
1740
1741 return true;
1742}
1743
1744
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001745/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1746/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1747/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1748/// will in fact be used.
1749static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1750 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1751 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1752 return true;
1753 }
1754
1755 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1756 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1757 return true;
1758 }
1759
1760 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1761 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1762 return true;
1763 }
1764
1765 return false;
1766}
1767
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001768ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001769Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001770 LookupResult &R,
1771 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001772 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1773 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001774 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001775 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1776 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001777
1778 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1779 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1780 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001781 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1782 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001783 return ExprError();
1784
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001785 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1786 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1787 // we've picked a target.
1788 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1789
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001790 bool Dependent
1791 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001792 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001793 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001794 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001795 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001796 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1797 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001798
1799 return Owned(ULE);
1800}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001801
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001802
1803/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001804ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001805Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001806 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1807 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001808 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001809 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1810 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001811
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001812 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001813 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1814 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001815
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001816 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1817 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1818 // a template argument list.
1819 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1820 << Template << SS.getRange();
1821 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1822 return ExprError();
1823 }
1824
1825 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1826 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1827 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001828 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001829 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001830 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001831 return ExprError();
1832 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001833
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001834 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1835 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1836 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1837 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001838 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001839 return ExprError();
1840
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001841 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1842 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001843 return ExprError();
1844
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001845 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1846 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1847 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1848 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001849 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001850 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1851 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1852 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001853 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001854 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001855 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1856 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1857 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1858 return ExprError();
1859 }
1860
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001861 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001862 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1863 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1864 return ExprError();
1865 }
1866
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001867 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001868 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001869 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001870 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001871 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001872 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1873 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001874 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001875
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001876 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001877 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001878 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1879 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001880 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001881 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1882 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1883 Expr *E = new (Context)
1884 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1885 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001886
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001887 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001888 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001889 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001890 SourceLocation(),
1891 Owned(E));
1892 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001893 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001894 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1895 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1896 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001897 }
1898 }
1899 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001900 }
1901 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1902 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001903
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001904 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1905 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001906}
1907
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001908ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001909 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001910 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001911
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001912 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001913 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001914 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1915 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1916 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001917 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001918
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001919 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1920 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001921
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001922 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001923 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1924 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001925 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001926 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001927 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001928 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001929
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001930 QualType ResTy;
1931 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1932 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1933 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001934 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001936 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001937 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001938 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1939 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001940 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001941}
1942
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001943ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001944 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001945 bool Invalid = false;
1946 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1947 if (Invalid)
1948 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001949
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001950 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1951 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001952 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001953 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001954
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001955 QualType Ty;
1956 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1957 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1958 else if (Literal.isWide())
1959 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001960 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1961 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001962 else
1963 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001964
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001965 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1966 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001967 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001968}
1969
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001970ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001972 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1973 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001974 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001975 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001976 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001977 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001978 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001979
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001980 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001981 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1982 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001983 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001984
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001985 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001986 bool Invalid = false;
1987 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1988 if (Invalid)
1989 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001990
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001991 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001992 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1993 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001994 return ExprError();
1995
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001996 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001997
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001998 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001999 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002000 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002001 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002002 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002003 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002004 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002005 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002006
2007 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2008
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002009 using llvm::APFloat;
2010 APFloat Val(Format);
2011
2012 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002013
2014 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2015 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2016 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2017 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002018 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002019 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002020 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002021 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002022 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2023 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002024 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002025 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2026 }
2027
2028 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2029 << Ty
2030 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2031 }
2032
2033 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002034 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002035
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002036 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002037 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002038 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002039 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002040
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002041 // long long is a C99 feature.
2042 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002043 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002044 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2045
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002046 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002047 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002048
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002049 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2050 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2051 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002052 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2053 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002054 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002055 } else {
2056 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2057 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002058
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002059 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2060 // be an unsigned int.
2061 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2062
2063 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002064 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002065 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2066 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002067 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002068
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002069 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2070 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2071 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2072 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002073 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002074 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002075 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002076 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002077 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002078 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002079
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002080 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002081 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002082 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002083
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002084 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2085 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2086 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2087 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002088 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002089 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002090 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002091 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002092 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002093 }
2094
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002095 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002096 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002097 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002098
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002099 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2100 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2101 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2102 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002103 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002104 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002105 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002106 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002107 }
2108 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002109
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002110 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2111 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002112 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002113 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002114 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002115 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002116 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002117
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002118 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2119 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002120 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002121 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002122 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002123
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002124 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2125 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002126 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002127 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002128
2129 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002130}
2131
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002132ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002133 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002134 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002135 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002136}
2137
2138/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2139/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002140bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002141 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002142 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002143 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002144 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2145 return false;
2146
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002147 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2148 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2149 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2150 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2151 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2152 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2153
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002154 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002155 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002156 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002157 if (isSizeof)
2158 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2159 return false;
2160 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002161
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002162 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002163 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002164 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2165 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002166 return false;
2167 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002168
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002169 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002170 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2171 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002172 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002173
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002174 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002175 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002176 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002177 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2178 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002179 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002180
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002181 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002182}
2183
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002184static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2185 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002186 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002187
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002188 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002189 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2190 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002191
2192 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2193 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2194 return false;
2195
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002196 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002197 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002198 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002199 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002200
2201 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2202 // bit-field.
2203 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002204 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002205 return false;
2206
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002207 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002208}
2209
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002210/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002211ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002212Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002213 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002214 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002215 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002216 return ExprError();
2217
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002218 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002219
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002220 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2221 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2222 return ExprError();
2223
2224 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002225 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002226 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2227 R.getEnd()));
2228}
2229
2230/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2231/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002232ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002233Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002234 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2235 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2236 bool isInvalid = false;
2237 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2238 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2239 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002240 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002241 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002242 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2243 isInvalid = true;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002244 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2245 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2246 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2247 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002248 } else {
2249 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2250 }
2251
2252 if (isInvalid)
2253 return ExprError();
2254
2255 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2256 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2257 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2258 R.getEnd()));
2259}
2260
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002261/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2262/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2263/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002264ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002265Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2266 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002267 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002268 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002269
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002270 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002271 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002272 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002273 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002274 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002275
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002276 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002277 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002278 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2279
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002280 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002281}
2282
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002283QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002284 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2285 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002286
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002287 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002288 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002289 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002290
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002291 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2292 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2293 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002294
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002295 // Test for placeholders.
2296 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2297 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2298 if (PR.take() != V) {
2299 V = PR.take();
2300 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2301 }
2302
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002303 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002304 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2305 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002306 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002307}
2308
2309
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002310
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002311ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002312Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002313 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002314 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002315 switch (Kind) {
2316 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002317 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2318 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002319 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002320
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002321 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002322}
2323
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002324ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002325Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2326 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002327 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002328 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002329 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2330 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002331
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002332 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002333
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002334 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002335 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002336 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2337 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2338 }
2339
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002340 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002341 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002342 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2343 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2344 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002345 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002346 }
2347
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002348 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002349}
2350
2351
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002352ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002353Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2354 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2355 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2356 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002357
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002358 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002359 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2360 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2361 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002362
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002363 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002364
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002365 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002366 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002367 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002368 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002369 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2370 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002371 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2372 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2373 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2374 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002375 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002376 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2377 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002378 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002379 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002380 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002381 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2382 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002383 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002384 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002385 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002386 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2387 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2388 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002389 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002390 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002391 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2392 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2393 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2394 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002395 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002396 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002397 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002398
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002399 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2400 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002401 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2402 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002403 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002404 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2405 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2406 // force the promotion here.
2407 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2408 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002409 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002410 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002411 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2412
2413 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2414 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002415 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002416 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2417 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2418 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2419 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002420 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002421 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002422 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2423
2424 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2425 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002426 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002427 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002428 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2429 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002430 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002431 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002432 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002433 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2434 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002435
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002436 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002437 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2438 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002439 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2440
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002441 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002442 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2443 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002444 // incomplete types are not object types.
2445 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2446 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2447 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2448 return ExprError();
2449 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002450
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002451 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2452 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2453 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2454 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2455 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002456 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002457 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2458 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002459 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002460
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002461 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002462 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002463 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2464 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2465 return ExprError();
2466 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002467
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002468 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002469 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002470}
2471
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002472QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002473CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002474 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002475 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002476 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2477 // see FIXME there.
2478 //
2479 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2480 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002481 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002482
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002483 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002484 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002485
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002486 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002487 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2488 // to be selected.
2489 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002490
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002491 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2492 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002493 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002494
2495 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2496 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002497 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002498 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2499 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002500 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002501 do
2502 compStr++;
2503 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002504 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002505 do
2506 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002507 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002508 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002509
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002510 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002511 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2512 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002513 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002514 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002515 return QualType();
2516 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002517
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002518 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2519 // operates on.
2520 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002521 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002522
2523 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002524 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002525
2526 while (*compStr) {
2527 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2528 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2529 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2530 return QualType();
2531 }
2532 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002533 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002534
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002535 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002536 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002537 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002538 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002539 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002540 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002541 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002542 if (HexSwizzle)
2543 CompSize--;
2544
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002545 if (CompSize == 1)
2546 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002547
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002548 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002549 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002550 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2551 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2552 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2553 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002554 }
2555 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002556}
2557
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002558static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002559 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002560 const Selector &Sel,
2561 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002562 if (Member)
2563 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2564 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002565 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002566 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002567
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002568 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2569 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002570 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2571 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002572 return D;
2573 }
2574 return 0;
2575}
2576
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002577static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2578 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2579 const Selector &Sel,
2580 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002581 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2582 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002583 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002584 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002585 if (Member)
2586 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2587 GDecl = PD;
2588 break;
2589 }
2590 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002591 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002592 GDecl = OMD;
2593 break;
2594 }
2595 }
2596 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002597 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002598 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2599 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002600 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2601 Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002602 if (GDecl)
2603 return GDecl;
2604 }
2605 }
2606 return GDecl;
2607}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002608
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002609ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002610Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002611 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002612 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2613 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002614 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002615 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2617 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2618 //
2619 // T* t;
2620 // t.f;
2621 //
2622 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2623 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2624 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2625 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002626 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002627 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2628 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002629 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002630 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002632 return ExprError();
2633 }
2634 }
2635
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002636 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2637 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002638 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002639
2640 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2641 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002642 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002643 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002644 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002645 SS.getRange(),
2646 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002647 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648}
2649
2650/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2651/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2652/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2653static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2654 Expr *BaseExpr,
2655 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002656 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002657 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002658 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2659 // diagnostics.
2660 if (!BaseExpr)
2661 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002662
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002663 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2664 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002665}
2666
2667// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2668// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2669// type. The restriction here is:
2670//
2671// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2672// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2673// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2674//
2675// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2676// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2677// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2678// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2679bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2680 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002681 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002682 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002683 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2684 if (!BaseRT) {
2685 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2686 // dependent.
2687 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2688 return false;
2689 }
2690 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002691
2692 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002693 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2694 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002695 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002696 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002697
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002698 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002699 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2700 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2701 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002702
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002703 if (!DC->isRecord())
2704 continue;
2705
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002706 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002707 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002708
2709 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2710 return false;
2711 }
2712
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002713 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002714 return true;
2715}
2716
2717static bool
2718LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2719 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002720 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2721 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2723 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002724 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002725 << BaseRange))
2726 return true;
2727
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002728 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2729 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2730 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2731
2732 bool MOUS;
2733 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2734 return false;
2735 }
2736
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002737 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2738 if (SS.isSet()) {
2739 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2740 // nested-name-specifier.
2741 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2742
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002743 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002744 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2745 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2746 return true;
2747 }
2748
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002749 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002750
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002751 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2752 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2753 << DC << SS.getRange();
2754 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002755 }
2756 }
2757
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002758 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2759 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002761 if (!R.empty())
2762 return false;
2763
2764 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2765 // for typos.
2766 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002767 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002768 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002769 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2770 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2771 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002772 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2773 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002774 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2775 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2776 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002777 return false;
2778 } else {
2779 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002780 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002781 }
2782
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002783 return false;
2784}
2785
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002786ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002787Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002788 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002789 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002790 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002791 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002792 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002793 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2794 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002795 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002796 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2797 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002798 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002799
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002800 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002801
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002802 // Implicit member accesses.
2803 if (!Base) {
2804 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2805 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2806 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2807 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002808 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002809 return ExprError();
2810
2811 // Explicit member accesses.
2812 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002813 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002814 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002815 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002816
2817 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2818 Owned(Base);
2819 return ExprError();
2820 }
2821
2822 if (Result.get())
2823 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002824
2825 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2826 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827 }
2828
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002829 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002830 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2831 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832}
2833
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002834ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002835Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002836 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2837 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002838 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002839 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002840 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2841 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002842 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002843 if (IsArrow) {
2844 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2845 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2846 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002847 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002849 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002850 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2851 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2852 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002853
2854 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002855 return ExprError();
2856
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857 if (R.empty()) {
2858 // Rederive where we looked up.
2859 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2860 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2861 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002862
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002864 << MemberName << DC
2865 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002866 return ExprError();
2867 }
2868
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002869 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2870 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2871 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2872 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2873 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2874 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2875 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2876 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2877 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2878 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002879 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002880 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002881 return ExprError();
2882
2883 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2884 // result.
2885 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002886 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002887 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002888 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002889 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002890
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002891 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2892 // pick a member.
2893 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2894
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2896 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2897 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002898 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2899 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002900 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002901 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002902 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002903
2904 return Owned(MemExpr);
2905 }
2906
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002907 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002908 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002909 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2910
2911 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2912
2913 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2914 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2915 // error cases.
2916 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2917 return ExprError();
2918
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002919 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2920 if (!BaseExpr) {
2921 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002922 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002923 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002924
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002925 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2926 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2927 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2928 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002929 }
2930
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002931 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2932 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2933 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2934 // explicitly qualified.
2935 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2936 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2937 }
2938
2939 // Check the use of this member.
2940 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2941 Owned(BaseExpr);
2942 return ExprError();
2943 }
2944
2945 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2946 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2947 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002948 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2949 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002950 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2951 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2952
2953 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2954 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2955 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2956 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2957 else {
2958 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2959 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2960 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2961
2962 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2963 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2964
2965 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2966 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2967 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2968 }
2969
2970 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002971 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002972 return ExprError();
2973 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002974 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2975 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002976 }
2977
2978 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2979 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2980 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002981 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002982 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2983 }
2984
2985 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2986 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2987 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002988 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002989 MemberFn->getType()));
2990 }
2991
2992 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2993 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2994 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002995 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2996 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002997 }
2998
2999 Owned(BaseExpr);
3000
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003001 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003002 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003003 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003004 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3005 else
3006 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3007 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003008
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003009 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3010 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003011 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003012 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003013}
3014
3015/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3016/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3017/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3018/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3019/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3020/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3021/// an ordinary member expression.
3022///
3023/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3024/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003025ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003026Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003027 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003028 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003029 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003030 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003031
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003032 // Perform default conversions.
3033 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003034
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003035 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003036 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3037
3038 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3039 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003040
3041 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003042 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003043 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3044 // call, and continue on.
3045 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3046 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3047 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3048 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3049 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003050 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3051 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003052 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3053 ->isRecordType()))) {
3054 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3055 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3056 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003057 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003058
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003059 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003060 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003061 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003062 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003063 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003064
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003065 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3066 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3067 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3068 }
3069 }
3070 }
3071
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003072 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3073 // use that.
3074 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003075 if (IsArrow) {
3076 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3077 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3078 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003079 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003080 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003081 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3082 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003083 }
3084 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003085 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3086 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3087 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3088 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003089 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003090 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003091 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003092
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003093 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3094 // use that.
3095 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3096 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3097 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3098 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3099 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003100 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003101 }
3102 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003103
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003104 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003105
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003106 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003107 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003108 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3109 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3110 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3111 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3112 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3113 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3114 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3115 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3116 // Check the use of this method.
3117 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3118 return ExprError();
3119 }
3120 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3121 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3122 Selector SetterSel =
3123 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3124 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3125 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3126 if (!Setter) {
3127 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3128 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003129 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003130 }
3131 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3132 if (!Setter)
3133 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003134
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003135 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3136 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003137
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003138 if (Getter || Setter) {
3139 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003140
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003141 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003142 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003143 else
3144 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3145 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3146 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003147 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003148 PType,
3149 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3150 }
3151 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3152 << MemberName << BaseType);
3153 }
3154 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003155
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003156 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3157 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3158 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003159 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003160 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003161
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003162 if (IsArrow) {
3163 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003164 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003165 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3166 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003167 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3168 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3169 // struct MyRecord foo;
3170 // foo->bar
3171 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3172 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3173 // by now.
3174 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3175 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003176 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003177 IsArrow = false;
3178 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003179 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3180 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3181 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003182 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003183 } else {
3184 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3185 // type *foo;
3186 // foo.bar
3187 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3188 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3189 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3190 // the appropriate pointer type
3191 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3192 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3193 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3194 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3195 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003196 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003197 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3198 IsArrow = true;
3199 }
3200 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003201 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003202
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003203 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003204 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003205 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003206 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003207 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003208 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003209 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003210
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003211 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3212 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003213 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003214 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003215 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003216 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3217 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3218 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3219 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003220 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3221
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003222 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003223 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003224
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003225 if (!IV) {
3226 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3227 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3228 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003229 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003230 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003231 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003232 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3233 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003234 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3235 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003236 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003237 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003238 } else {
3239 Res.clear();
3240 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003241 }
3242 }
3243
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003244 if (IV) {
3245 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3246 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3247 // error cases.
3248 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3249 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003250
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003251 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3252 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3253 return ExprError();
3254 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3255 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3256 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3257 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3258 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3259 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3260 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3261 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3262 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3263 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3264 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3265 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003266 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003267 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003268 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3269 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003270 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003271 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3272 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003273
3274 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3275 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003276 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003277 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003278 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003279 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3280 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003281 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003282 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003283 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003284
3285 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3286 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003287 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003288 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003289 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003290 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003291 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003292 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003293 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003294 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003295 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3296 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003297 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003298 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003299
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003300 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003301 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003302 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3303 Context)) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003304 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3305 // Check the use of this declaration
3306 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3307 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003308
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003309 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3310 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3311 }
3312 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3313 // Check the use of this method.
3314 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3315 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003316 Selector SetterSel =
3317 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3318 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3319 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3320 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3321 SetterSel, Context))
3322 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3323 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3324 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3325 SMD,
3326 MemberLoc,
3327 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003328 }
3329 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003330
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003331 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003332 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003333 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003334
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003335 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3336 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003337 if (!IsArrow)
3338 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3339 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003340 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003341
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003342 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003343 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003344 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3345 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003346 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003347 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003348 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003349
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003350 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003351 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003352 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003353 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3354 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003355 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003356 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003357 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003358 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003359
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003360 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3361 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3362
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003363 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003364}
3365
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003366/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3367/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3368/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3369/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3370/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3371///
3372/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3373/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3374/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3375/// only be called
3376/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3377/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3378/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003379ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003380 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3381 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003382 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003383 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003384 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003385 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3386 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3387 return ExprError();
3388
3389 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3390
3391 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003392 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003393 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3394 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003395 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003396
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003397 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003398 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3399
3400 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3401 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3402 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3403
3404 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003405 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003406 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3407 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003408
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003409 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3410 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003411 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003412 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3413 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003414 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003415 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003416 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003417 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3418 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003419
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003420 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3421 Owned(Base);
3422 return ExprError();
3423 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003424
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003425 if (Result.get()) {
3426 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3427 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3428 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3429 // call now.
3430 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3431 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003432 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003433
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003434 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003435 }
3436
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003437 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003438 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3439 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003440 }
3441
3442 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003443}
3444
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003445ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003446 FunctionDecl *FD,
3447 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3448 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003449 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003450 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3451 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003452 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003453 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003454 return ExprError();
3455 }
3456
3457 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3458 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003459
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003460 // Instantiate the expression.
3461 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3462 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003463
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003464 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3465 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3466 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3467 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003468
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003469 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3470 if (Result.isInvalid())
3471 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003472
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003473 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3474 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003475 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003476 InitializationKind Kind
3477 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3478 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3479 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003480
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003481 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3482 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3483 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3484 if (Result.isInvalid())
3485 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003486
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003487 // Build the default argument expression.
3488 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3489 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003490 }
3491
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003492 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3493 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3494 // be properly destroyed.
3495 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3496 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003497 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3498 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3499 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3500 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3501 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3502 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003503
3504 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003505 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3506 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003507 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003508 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003509}
3510
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003511/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3512/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3513/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3514/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3515/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3516/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003517bool
3518Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003519 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003520 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003521 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3522 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003523 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003524 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3525 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003526 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003527
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003528 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3529 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3530 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3531 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3532 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003533 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003534 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003535 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003536 }
3537
3538 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3539 // them.
3540 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3541 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3542 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3543 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003544 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003545 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003546 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3547 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3548 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003549 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003550 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003551 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003552 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003553 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003554 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003555 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3556 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3557 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3558 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3559 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003560 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003561 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003562 if (Invalid)
3563 return true;
3564 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3565 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3566 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003567
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003568 return false;
3569}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003570
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003571bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3572 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3573 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3574 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3575 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3576 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003577 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003578 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3579 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3580 bool Invalid = false;
3581 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3582 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3583 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3584 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003585 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003586 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003587 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003588
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003589 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003590 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3591 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003592
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003593 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3594 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003595 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003596 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003597 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003598
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003599 // Pass the argument
3600 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3601 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3602 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003603
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003604 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003605 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3606 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003607 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003608 SourceLocation(),
3609 Owned(Arg));
3610 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3611 return true;
3612
3613 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003614 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003615 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003616
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003617 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003618 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003619 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3620 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003621
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003622 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003623 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003624 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003625 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003626
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003627 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003628 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003629 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003630 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003631 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003632 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003633 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003634 }
3635 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003636 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003637}
3638
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003639/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003640/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3641/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003642ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003643Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003644 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003645 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003646
3647 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003648 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003649 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3650 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003651
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003652 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003653
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003654 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003655 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3656 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3657 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3658 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3659 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003660 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003661 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3662 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003663
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003664 NumArgs = 0;
3665 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003666
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003667 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3668 RParenLoc));
3669 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003670
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003671 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003672 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003673 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3674 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003675 bool Dependent = false;
3676 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3677 Dependent = true;
3678 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3679 Dependent = true;
3680
3681 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003682 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003683 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3684
3685 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3686 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3687 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003688 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003689
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003690 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3691
3692 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3693 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3694 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3695 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3696 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3697 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3698 // method template.
3699 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003700 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3701 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003702 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003703
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003704 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003705 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003706 }
3707
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003708 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003709 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003710 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003711 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003712 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003713 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003714 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003715
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003716 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003717 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003718 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3719 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003720 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3721 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003722 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003723
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003724 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3725 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3726 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3727 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003728
3729 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3730 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003731 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003732 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003733
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003734 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003735 RParenLoc))
3736 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003737
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003738 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003739 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003740 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003741 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3742 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003743 }
3744 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003745 }
3746
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003747 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003748 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003749 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003750
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003751 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003752 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3753 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003754 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003755 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003756 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003757
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003758 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3759 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3760 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3761
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003762 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3763}
3764
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003765/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3766/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003767/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3768/// block-pointer type.
3769///
3770/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003771ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003772Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3773 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3774 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3775 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3776 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3777
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003778 // Promote the function operand.
3779 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3780
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003781 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3782 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003783 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3784 Args, NumArgs,
3785 Context.BoolTy,
3786 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003787
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003788 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3789 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3790 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3791 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003792 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003793 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003794 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3795 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003796 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003797 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003798 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003799 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003800 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003801 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003802 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3803 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3804
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003805 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003806 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003807 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003808 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003809 return ExprError();
3810
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003811 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003812 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003813
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003814 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003815 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003816 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003817 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003818 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003819 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003820
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003821 if (FDecl) {
3822 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3823 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3824 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003825 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003826 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003827 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003828 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3829 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3830 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3831 }
3832 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003833 }
3834
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003835 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003836 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3837 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3838 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003839 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3840 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003841 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3842 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003843 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003844 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003845 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003846 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003847
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003848 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3849 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003850 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3851 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003852
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003853 // Check for sentinels
3854 if (NDecl)
3855 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003856
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003857 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003858 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003859 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003860 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003861
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003862 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003863 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003864 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003865 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003866 return ExprError();
3867 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003868
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003869 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003870}
3871
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003872ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003873Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003874 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003875 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003876 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003877 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003878
3879 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3880 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3881 if (!TInfo)
3882 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3883
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003884 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003885}
3886
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003887ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003888Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003889 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003890 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003891
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003892 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003893 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003894 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3895 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003896 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3897 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003898 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003899 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003900 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003901 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003902
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003903 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003904 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003905 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003906 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003907 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003908 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003909 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003910 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003911 &literalType);
3912 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003913 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003914 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003915
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003916 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003917 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003918 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003919 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003920 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003921
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003922 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003923 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003924}
3925
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003926ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003927Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003928 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3929 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003930 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003931
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003932 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003933 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003934
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003935 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3936 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003937 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003938 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003939}
3940
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003941static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003942 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003943 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003944 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003945
3946 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3947 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003948 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003949 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3950 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003951 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003952 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003953 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003954
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003955 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3956 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003957 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003958 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003959 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003960 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003961 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003962 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003963
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003964 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3965 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003966 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003967 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003968 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003969 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003971 // FIXME: Assert here.
3972 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003973 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003974}
3975
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003976/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003977bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003978 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003979 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003980 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003981 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003982 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3983 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003984
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003985 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003986
3987 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3988 // type needs to be scalar.
3989 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3990 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003991 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003992 return false;
3993 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003994
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003995 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3996 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3997 return true;
3998
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003999 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004000 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004001 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4002 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004003 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004004 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4005 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004006 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004007 return false;
4008 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004009
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004010 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004011 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004012 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004013 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004014 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004015 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004017 castExpr->getType()) &&
4018 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004019 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4020 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4021 break;
4022 }
4023 }
4024 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4025 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4026 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004027 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004028 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004029 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004030
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004031 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4032 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4033 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4034 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004035
4036 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004037 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004038 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4039 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004040 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004041 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004042
4043 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004044 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004045
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004046 if (castType->isVectorType())
4047 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4048 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4049 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4050
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004051 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4052 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004053
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004054 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004055 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004056 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004057 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004058 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4059 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4060 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4061 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004062 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004063 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4064 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4065 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004066 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004067
4068 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004069
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004070 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004071 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4072
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004073 return false;
4074}
4075
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004076bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004077 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004078 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004079
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004080 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004081 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004082 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004083 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004084 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004085 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004086 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004087 } else
4088 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004089 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004090 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004091
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004092 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004093 return false;
4094}
4095
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004096bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004097 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004098 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004099
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004100 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004101
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004102 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4103 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004104 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4105 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4106 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4107 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004108 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004109 return false;
4110 }
4111
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004112 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004113 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4114 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004115 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4116 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4117 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4118 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004119
4120 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4121 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4122 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004123
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004124 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004125 return false;
4126}
4127
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004128ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004129Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004130 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4131 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004132 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004133
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004134 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4135 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4136 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004137 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004138
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004139 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4140 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004141 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004142 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004143
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004144 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004145}
4146
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004147ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004148Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004149 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004150 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004151 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004152 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004153 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004154 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004155
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004156 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004157 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004158 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4159 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004160}
4161
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004162/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4163/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004164ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004165Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004166 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4167 if (!E)
4168 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004169
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004170 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004171
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004172 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004173 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4174 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004175
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004176 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4177
4178 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004179}
4180
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004181ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004182Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004183 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004184 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004185 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004186 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004187 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004188
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004189 // Check for an altivec literal,
4190 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004191 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4192 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4193 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4194 return ExprError();
4195 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004196 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4197 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4198 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4199 }
4200 else
4201 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4202 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004203
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004204 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4205 // then handle it as such.
4206 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004207 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4208 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4209 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4210
4211 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4212 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004213 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4214 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004215 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4216 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004217 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004218 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004219 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004220 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004221 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004222 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4223 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004224 }
4225}
4226
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004227ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004228 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004229 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004230 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004231 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4232 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004233 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4234 Expr *expr;
4235 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4236 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4237 else
4238 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004239 return Owned(expr);
4240}
4241
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004242/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4243/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004244/// C99 6.5.15
4245QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004246 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004247 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004248 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4249 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004250 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004251
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004252 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004253 if (SAVE) {
4254 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4255 }
4256 else
4257 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004258 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4259 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4260 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4261 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004262
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004263 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004264 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004265 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4266 // Throw an error if its not either.
4267 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4268 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4269 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4270 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4271 << CondTy;
4272 return QualType();
4273 }
4274 }
4275 else {
4276 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4277 << CondTy;
4278 return QualType();
4279 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004280 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004281
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004282 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004283 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4284 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004285
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004286 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4287 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4288 // built in select.
4289 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4290 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4291 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4292 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4293 << CondTy;
4294 return QualType();
4295 }
4296 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4297 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4298 << CondTy;
4299 return QualType();
4300 }
4301 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4302 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4303 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4304 }
4305
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004306 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4307 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004308 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4309 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4310 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004311 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004312
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004313 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4314 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004315 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4316 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004317 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004318 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004319 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004320 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004321 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004322 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004323
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004324 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004325 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004326 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4327 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4328 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4329 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4330 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4331 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4332 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004333 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4334 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004335 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004336 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004337 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4338 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004339 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004340 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004341 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004342 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004343 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004344 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004345 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004346 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004347 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004348 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004349 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004350
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004351 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4352 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4353 QuestionLoc);
4354 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4355 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004356
4357
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004358 // Handle block pointer types.
4359 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4360 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4361 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4362 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004363 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4364 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004365 return destType;
4366 }
4367 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004368 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004369 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004370 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004371 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4372 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4373 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004374 return LHSTy;
4375 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004376 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004377 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4378 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004379
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004380 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4381 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004382 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004383 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004384 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4385 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4386 // to get a consistent AST.
4387 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004388 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4389 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004390 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004391 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004392 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004393 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4394 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004395 return LHSTy;
4396 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004397
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004398 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4399 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4400 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004401 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4402 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004403
4404 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4405 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4406 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004407 QualType destPointee
4408 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004409 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004410 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004411 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004412 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004413 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004414 return destType;
4415 }
4416 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004417 QualType destPointee
4418 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004419 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004420 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004421 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004422 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004423 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004424 return destType;
4425 }
4426
4427 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4428 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4429 return LHSTy;
4430 }
4431 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4432 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4433 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4434 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4435 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4436 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4437 // to get a consistent AST.
4438 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004439 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4440 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004441 return incompatTy;
4442 }
4443 // The pointer types are compatible.
4444 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4445 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4446 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4447 // type.
4448 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4449 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004450 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4451 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004452 return LHSTy;
4453 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004454
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004455 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4456 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4457 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4458 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004459 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004460 return RHSTy;
4461 }
4462 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4463 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4464 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004465 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004466 return LHSTy;
4467 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004468
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004469 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004470 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4471 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004472 return QualType();
4473}
4474
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004475/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4476/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4477QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4478 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4479 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4480 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004481
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004482 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4483 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4484 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4485 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4486 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004487 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004488 return LHSTy;
4489 }
4490 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4491 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004492 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004493 return RHSTy;
4494 }
4495 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4496 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4497 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004498 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004499 return LHSTy;
4500 }
4501 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4502 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004503 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004504 return RHSTy;
4505 }
4506 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4507 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4508 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004509 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004510 return LHSTy;
4511 }
4512 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4513 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004514 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004515 return RHSTy;
4516 }
4517 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4518 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004519
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004520 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4521 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4522 return LHSTy;
4523 }
4524 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4525 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4526 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004527
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004528 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4529 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4530 // type. This allows
4531 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4532 // where B is a subclass of A.
4533 //
4534 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4535 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4536 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4537 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004538
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004539 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4540 // It could return the composite type.
4541 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4542 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4543 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4544 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4545 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4546 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4547 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4548 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4549 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4550 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4551 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4552 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4553 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4554 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004555 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004556 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4557 ;
4558 else {
4559 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4560 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4561 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4562 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004563 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4564 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004565 return incompatTy;
4566 }
4567 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004568 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4569 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004570 return compositeType;
4571 }
4572 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4573 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4574 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4575 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4576 QualType destPointee
4577 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4578 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4579 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004580 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004581 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004582 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004583 return destType;
4584 }
4585 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4586 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4587 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4588 QualType destPointee
4589 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4590 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4591 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004592 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004593 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004594 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004595 return destType;
4596 }
4597 return QualType();
4598}
4599
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004600/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004601/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004602ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004603 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004604 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4605 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004606 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4607 // was the condition.
4608 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004609 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4610 if (isLHSNull) {
4611 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4612 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004613
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004614 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4615 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004616 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004617 return ExprError();
4618
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004619 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004620 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4621 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4622 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004623}
4624
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004625// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004626// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004627// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4628// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4629// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004630Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004631Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4632 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004633
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004634 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4635 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4636 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4637 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4638 return Compatible;
4639 }
4640
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004641 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004642 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4643 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004644
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004645 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004646 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4647 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004648
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004649 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004650
4651 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4652 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4653 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004654 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004655 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004656 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004657
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004658 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4659 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004660 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004661 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004662 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004663 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004664
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004665 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004666 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4667 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004668 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004669
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004670 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004671 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004672 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004673
4674 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004675 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4676 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004677 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004678 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004679 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004680 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4681 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4682 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4683 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4684 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4685 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004686 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004687 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004688 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004689 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004690
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004691 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004692 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004693 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004694 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004695
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004696 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4697 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4698 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4699 // warning can be disabled.
4700 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4701 return ConvTy;
4702 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4703 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004704
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004705 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4706 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4707 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4708 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4709 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4710 do {
4711 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4712 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004713
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004714 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4715 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4716 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004717
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004718 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004719 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004720 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004721
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004722 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004723 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004724 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004725 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004726}
4727
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004728/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4729/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4730/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4731// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004732Sema::AssignConvertType
4733Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004734 QualType rhsType) {
4735 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004736
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004737 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004738 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4739 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004740
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004741 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4742 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4743 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004744
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004745 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004746
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004747 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004748 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004749 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004750
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004751 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4752 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4753 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4754 }
4755 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004756 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004757 return ConvTy;
4758}
4759
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004760/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4761/// for assignment compatibility.
4762Sema::AssignConvertType
4763Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004764 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4765 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004766 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4767 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004768 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004769 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004770 }
4771 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4772 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004773 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4774 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004775 return IncompatiblePointer;
4776 return Compatible;
4777 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004778 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004779 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004780 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004781 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4782 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4783 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4784 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4785 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4786 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004787
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004788 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4789 return Compatible;
4790 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4791 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004792 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004793}
4794
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004795/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4796/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004797/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4798///
4799/// int a, *pint;
4800/// short *pshort;
4801/// struct foo *pfoo;
4802///
4803/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4804/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4805/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4806/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4807///
4808/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004809/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004810///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004811Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004812Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004813 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4814 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004815 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4816 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004817
4818 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004819 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004820
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004821 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4822 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4823 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4824 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4825 return Compatible;
4826 }
4827
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004828 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4829 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4830 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4831 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4832 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4833 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4834 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004835 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004836 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004837 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004838 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004839 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004840 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4841 // to the same ExtVector type.
4842 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4843 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4844 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004845 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004846 return Compatible;
4847 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004848
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004849 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004850 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4851 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4852 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4853 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4854 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4855 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004856 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004857
4858 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4859 // vector type and vice versa
4860 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4861 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004862 }
4863 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004864 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004865
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004866 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4867 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004868 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004869
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004870 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004871 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004872 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004873
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004874 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004875 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004876
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004877 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004878 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004879 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4880 return Compatible;
4881 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004882 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004883 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4884 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004885 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004886
4887 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004888 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004889 return Compatible;
4890 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004891 return Incompatible;
4892 }
4893
4894 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4895 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004896 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004897
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004898 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004899 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004900 return Compatible;
4901
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004902 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4903 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004904
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004905 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004906 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004907 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004908 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004909 return Incompatible;
4910 }
4911
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004912 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4913 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4914 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004915
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004916 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004917 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004918 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4919 return Compatible;
4920 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004921 }
4922 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004923 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004924 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004925 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004926 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4927 return Compatible;
4928 }
4929 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4930 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4931 return Compatible;
4932 return Incompatible;
4933 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004934 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004935 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004936 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4937 return Compatible;
4938
4939 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004940 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004941
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004942 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004943 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004944
4945 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004946 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004947 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004948 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004949 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004950 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4951 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4952 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4953 return Compatible;
4954
4955 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4956 return PointerToInt;
4957
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004958 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004959 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004960 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4961 return Compatible;
4962 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004963 }
4964 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004965 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004966 return Compatible;
4967 return Incompatible;
4968 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004969
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004970 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004971 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004972 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004973 }
4974 return Incompatible;
4975}
4976
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004977/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4978/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004979static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004980 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4981 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4982 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004983 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004984 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004985 SourceLocation());
4986 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4987 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4988
4989 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4990 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004991 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004992 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004993 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004994}
4995
4996Sema::AssignConvertType
4997Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4998 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4999
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005000 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005001 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5002 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005003 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005004 return Incompatible;
5005
5006 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5007 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5008 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5009 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005010 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5011 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005012 it != itend; ++it) {
5013 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5014 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5015 // 1) void pointer
5016 // 2) null pointer constant
5017 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005018 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005019 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005020 InitField = *it;
5021 break;
5022 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005023
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005024 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005025 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005026 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005027 InitField = *it;
5028 break;
5029 }
5030 }
5031
5032 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5033 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005034 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005035 InitField = *it;
5036 break;
5037 }
5038 }
5039
5040 if (!InitField)
5041 return Incompatible;
5042
5043 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5044 return Compatible;
5045}
5046
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005047Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005048Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005049 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5050 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5051 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5052 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5053 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005054 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005055 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005056 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005057 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005058 }
5059
5060 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5061 // structures.
5062 }
5063
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005064 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5065 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005066 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5067 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005068 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005069 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005070 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005071 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005072 return Compatible;
5073 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005074
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005075 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005076 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005077 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005078 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005079 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005080 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005081 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005082 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005083
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005084 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5085 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005086
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005087 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5088 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005089 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5090 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5091 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5092 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005093 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005094 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005095 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005096 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005097}
5098
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005099QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005100 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005101 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005102 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005103 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005104}
5105
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005106QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005107 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005108 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005109 QualType lhsType =
5110 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5111 QualType rhsType =
5112 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005113
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005114 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005115 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005116 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005117
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005118 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5119 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005120 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005121 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005122 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005123 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005124 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005125 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005126 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005127 return lhsType;
5128 }
5129
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005130 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005131 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005132 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5133 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5134 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5135 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5136 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5137 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005138 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005139 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005140 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005141 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005142
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005143 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5144 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5145 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005146 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005147 return rhsType;
5148 }
5149
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005150 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5151 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5152 bool swapped = false;
5153 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5154 swapped = true;
5155 std::swap(rex, lex);
5156 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5157 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005158
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005159 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005160 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005161 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005162 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005163 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005164 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005165 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5166 return lhsType;
5167 }
5168 }
5169 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5170 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5171 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005172 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005173 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5174 return lhsType;
5175 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005176 }
5177 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005178
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005179 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005180 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005181 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005182 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005183 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005184}
5185
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005186QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5187 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005188 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005189 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005190
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005191 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005192
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005193 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5194 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5195 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005196
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005197 // Check for division by zero.
5198 if (isDiv &&
5199 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005200 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005201 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005202
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005203 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005204}
5205
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005206QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005207 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005208 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005209 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5210 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005211 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5212 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5213 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005214
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005215 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005216
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005217 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5218 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005219
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005220 // Check for remainder by zero.
5221 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005222 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5223 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005224
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005225 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005226}
5227
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005228QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005229 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005230 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5231 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5232 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5233 return compType;
5234 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005235
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005236 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005237
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005238 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005239 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5240 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5241 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005242 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005243 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005244
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005245 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5246 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005247 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005248 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5249
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005250 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005251
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005252 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005253 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005254
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005255 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5256 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005257 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5258 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005259 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005260 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005261 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005262
5263 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5264 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5265 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005266 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005267 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5268 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5269 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5270 return QualType();
5271 }
5272
5273 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5274 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5275 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005276 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005277 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005278 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005279 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005280 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5281 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005282 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5283 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005284 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005285 return QualType();
5286 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005287 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005288 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005289 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5290 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5291 return QualType();
5292 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005293
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005294 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005295 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5296 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5297 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5298 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5299 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005300 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005301 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5302 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005303 return PExp->getType();
5304 }
5305 }
5306
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005307 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005308}
5309
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005310// C99 6.5.6
5311QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005312 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5313 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5314 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5315 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5316 return compType;
5317 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005318
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005319 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005320
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005321 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005322
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005323 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005324 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5325 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005326 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005327 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005328 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005329
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005330 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005331 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005332 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005333
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005334 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005335
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005336 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5337 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5338 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5339 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5340 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5341 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5342 return QualType();
5343 }
5344
5345 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5346 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5347 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5348 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5349 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005350 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005351 return QualType();
5352 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005353
5354 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5355 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5356 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005357 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005358 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005359 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005360 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005361 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005362
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005363 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005364 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005365 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5366 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5367 return QualType();
5368 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005369
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005370 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005371 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5372 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5373 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5374 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5375 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5376 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005377 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005378 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5379
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005380 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005381 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005382 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005383
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005384 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005385 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005386 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005387
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005388 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5389 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5390 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5392 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5393 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5394 return QualType();
5395 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005396
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005397 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5398 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5399 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5400 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005401 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005402 return QualType();
5403 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005404
5405 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5406 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5407 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5408 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5409 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005410 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5411 << rex->getSourceRange()
5412 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005413 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005414
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005415 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5416 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5417 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5418 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5419 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5420 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5421 return QualType();
5422 }
5423 } else {
5424 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5425 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5426 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5427 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5428 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5429 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5430 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5431 return QualType();
5432 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005433 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005434
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005435 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5436 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5437 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5438 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5439 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005440 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005441 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005442
5443 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005444 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5445 }
5446 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005447
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005448 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005449}
5450
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005451static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5452 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5453 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5454 return false;
5455}
5456
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005457// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005458QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005459 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005460 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005461 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5462 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005463 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005464
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005465 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5466 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5467 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5468 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5469 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5470 }
5471
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005472 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5473 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5474 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5475
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005476 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5477 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005478 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5479 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5480 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5481 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5482 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005483 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005484 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005485 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005486
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005487 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005488
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005489 // Sanity-check shift operands
5490 llvm::APSInt Right;
5491 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005492 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5493 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005494 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005495 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5496 else {
5497 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5498 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5499 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5500 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5501 }
5502 }
5503
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005504 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005505 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005506}
5507
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005508static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5509 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5510 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5511 return true;
5512 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5513 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5514 }
5515 return false;
5516}
5517
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005518// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005519QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005520 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005521 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005522
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005523 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005524 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005525 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005526
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005527 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5528 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005529
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005530 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005531 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5532 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5533 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005534 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5535 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5536 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005537 //
5538 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5539 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5540 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5541 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5542 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5543 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005544 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5545 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005546 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005547 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005548 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005549 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005550 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5551 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005552 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5553 || Opc == BO_LE
5554 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005555 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5556 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5557 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5558 // what is it always going to eval to?
5559 char always_evals_to;
5560 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005561 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005562 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5563 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005564 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005565 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5566 break;
5567 default:
5568 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5569 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5570 break;
5571 }
5572 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5573 << 1 // array
5574 << always_evals_to);
5575 }
5576 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005577 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005578
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005579 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5580 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5581 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5582 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005583
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005584 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5585 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005586 Expr *literalString = 0;
5587 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005588 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005589 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005590 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005591 literalString = lex;
5592 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005593 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5594 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005595 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005596 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005597 literalString = rex;
5598 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5599 }
5600
5601 if (literalString) {
5602 std::string resultComparison;
5603 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005604 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5605 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5606 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5607 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5608 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5609 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005610 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5611 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005612
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005613 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5614 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5615 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005616 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005617 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005618 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005619
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005620 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5621 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5622 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5623 else {
5624 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5625 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5626 }
5627
5628 lType = lex->getType();
5629 rType = rex->getType();
5630
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005631 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005632 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005633
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005634 if (isRelational) {
5635 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005636 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005637 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005638 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005639 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005640 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005641
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005642 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005643 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005644 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005645
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005646 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005647 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005648 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005649 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005650
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005651 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5652 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005653 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005654 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005655 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005656 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005657 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005658
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005659 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005660 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5661 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005662 if (!isRelational &&
5663 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5664 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5665 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005666 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5667 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005668 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5669 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005670 Diag(Loc,
5671 isSFINAEContext()?
5672 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5673 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005674 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005675
5676 if (isSFINAEContext())
5677 return QualType();
5678
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005679 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005680 return ResultTy;
5681 }
5682 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005683 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5684 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5685 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5686 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5687 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5688 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005689 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005690 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005691 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005692 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005693 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005694 if (T.isNull()) {
5695 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5696 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5697 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005698 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005699 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005700 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005701 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005702 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005703 }
5704
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005705 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5706 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005707 return ResultTy;
5708 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005709 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5710 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5711 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5712 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5713 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5714 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5715 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5716 }
5717 } else if (!isRelational &&
5718 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5719 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5720 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5721 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5722 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5723 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5724 }
5725 } else {
5726 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005727 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005728 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005729 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005730 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005731 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005732 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005733 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005734
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005735 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005736 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005737 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005738 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005739 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5740 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005741 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5742 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005743 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5744 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005745 return ResultTy;
5746 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005747 if (LHSIsNull &&
5748 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5749 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005750 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5751 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005752 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5753 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005754 return ResultTy;
5755 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005756
5757 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005758 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005759 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5760 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005761 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5762 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5763 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5764 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5765 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5766 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5767 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5768 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005769 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005770 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005771 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005772 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005773 if (T.isNull()) {
5774 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005775 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005776 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005777 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005778 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005779 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005780 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005781 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005782 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005783
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005784 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5785 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005786 return ResultTy;
5787 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005788
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005789 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005790 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5791 return ResultTy;
5792 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005793
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005794 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005795 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005796 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5797 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005798
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005799 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005800 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005801 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005802 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005803 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005804 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005805 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005806 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005807 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005808 if (!isRelational
5809 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5810 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005811 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005812 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005813 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005814 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005815 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5816 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5817 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005818 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005819 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005820 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005821 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005822
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005823 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005824 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005825 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5826 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005827 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005828 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005829 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005830 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005831
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005832 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5833 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005834 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005835 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005836 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005837 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005838 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005839 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005840 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005841 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005842 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5843 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005844 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005845 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005846 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005847 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005848 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5849 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005850 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005851 bool isError = false;
5852 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5853 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5854 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005855 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005856 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005857 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005858 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5859 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5860 isError = true;
5861 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005862 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005863
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005864 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005865 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005866 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005867 if (isError)
5868 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005869 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005870
5871 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005872 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005873 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005874 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005875 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005876 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005877
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005878 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005879 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5880 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005881 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005882 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005883 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005884 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5885 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005886 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005887 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005888 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005889 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005890}
5891
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005892/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005893/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005894/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5895/// types.
5896QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005897 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005898 bool isRelational) {
5899 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5900 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005901 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005902 if (vType.isNull())
5903 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005904
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005905 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5906 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005907
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005908 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5909 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5910 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005911 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005912 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5913 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5914 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005915 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5916 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5917 << 0 // self-
5918 << 2 // "a constant"
5919 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005920 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005921
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005922 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005923 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5924 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005925 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005926 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005927
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005928 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5929 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5930 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005931 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005932 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005933
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005934 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005935 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005936 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005937 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005938 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005939 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5940
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005941 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005942 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005943 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5944}
5945
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005946inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005947 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005948 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5949 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5950 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5951 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5952
5953 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5954 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005955
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005956 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005957
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005958 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5959 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005960 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005961 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005962}
5963
5964inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005965 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5966
5967 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5968 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5969 // is a constant.
5970 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005971 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005972 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005973 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5974 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5975 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5976 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5977 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5978 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5979 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5980 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5981 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005982 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5983 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005984 }
5985 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005986
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005987 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5988 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5989 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005990
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005991 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5992 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005993
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005994 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005995 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005996
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005997 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5998 // non-overloadable operands.
5999
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006000 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6001 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006002 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6003 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6004 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006005 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006006
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006007 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6008 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6009 // The result is a bool.
6010 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006011}
6012
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006013/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6014/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6015/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6016///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006017static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006018 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6019 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6020 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
6021 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006022 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006023 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6024 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6025 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6026 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006027 }
6028 }
6029 return false;
6030}
6031
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006032/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6033/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6034static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006035 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006036 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006037 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006038 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6039 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006040 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6041 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006042
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006043 unsigned Diag = 0;
6044 bool NeedType = false;
6045 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006046 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006047 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006048 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6049 NeedType = true;
6050 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006051 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006052 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6053 NeedType = true;
6054 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006055 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006056 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6057 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006058 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6059 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006060 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006061 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6062 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006063 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6064 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006065 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6066 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006067 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006068 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006069 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006070 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006071 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6072 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006073 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006074 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6075 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006076 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6077 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6078 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006079 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6080 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6081 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006082 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6083 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6084 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006085 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006086
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006087 SourceRange Assign;
6088 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6089 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006090 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006091 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006092 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006093 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006094 return true;
6095}
6096
6097
6098
6099// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006100QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6101 SourceLocation Loc,
6102 QualType CompoundType) {
6103 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6104 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006105 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006106
6107 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6108 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006109 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006110 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006111 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006112 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006113 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006114 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006115 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6116 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6117 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006118 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006119 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006120 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006121 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006122
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006123 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6124 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6125 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006126 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006127 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6128 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6129 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006130 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6131 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006132 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006133 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006134 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6135 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6136 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006137 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6138 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006139 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006140 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006141 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006142 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006143 }
6144 } else {
6145 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006146 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006147 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006148
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006149 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006150 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006151 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006152
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006153
6154 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6155 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6156 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6157 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6158 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6159 // check.
6160 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006161 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006162 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6163 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6164 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6165 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6166 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6167 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6168 }
6169
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006170 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6171 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006172 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006173 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6174 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006175 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006176 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006177 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6178 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006179}
6180
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006181// C99 6.5.17
6182QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006183 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6184
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006185 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6186 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6187 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6188 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6189 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6190 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6191 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006192
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006193 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6194 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6195 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6196 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006197
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006198 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006199}
6200
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006201/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6202/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006203QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006204 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006205 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6206 return Context.DependentTy;
6207
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006208 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6209 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006210
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006211 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6212 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6213 if (!isInc) {
6214 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6215 return QualType();
6216 }
6217 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6218 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6219 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006220 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006221 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6222 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006223
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006224 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006225 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006226 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6227 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6228 << Op->getSourceRange();
6229 return QualType();
6230 }
6231
6232 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006233 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006234 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006235 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6236 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6237 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6238 return QualType();
6239 }
6240
6241 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006242 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006243 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006244 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006245 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006246 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006247 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006248 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006249 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006250 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6251 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6252 return QualType();
6253 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006254 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006255 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6256 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006257 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006258 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6259 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6260 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6261 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006262 } else {
6263 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006264 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006265 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006266 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006267 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006268 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006269 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006270 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006271 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6272 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6273 // operand.
6274 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6275 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006276}
6277
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006278void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6279 bool copyInit = false;
6280 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6281 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6282 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6283 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6284 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6285 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6286 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6287 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6288 }
6289 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6290 }
6291 else
6292 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6293 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6294 if (copyInit) {
6295 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006296 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006297 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6298 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6299 Owned(Arg));
6300 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006301 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006302 }
6303}
6304
6305
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006306/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006307/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006308/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6309/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6310/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6311/// - &(x) => x
6312/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6313/// - &s.xx => s
6314/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6315/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6316/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6317/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006318static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006319 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006320 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006321 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006322 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006323 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6324 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6325 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006326 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006327 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006328 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006329 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006330 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006331 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6332 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006333 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6334 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6335 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6336 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6337 }
6338 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006339 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006340 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6341 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006342
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006343 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006344 case UO_Real:
6345 case UO_Imag:
6346 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006347 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6348 default:
6349 return 0;
6350 }
6351 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006352 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006353 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006354 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006355 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6356 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006357 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006358 default:
6359 return 0;
6360 }
6361}
6362
6363/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006364/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006365/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006366/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006367/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006368/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006369/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006370QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6371 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006372 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006373 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6374 return Context.OverloadTy;
6375
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006376 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6377 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6378 OrigOp = PR.take();
6379
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006380 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6381 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006382
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006383 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6384 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6385 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006386 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006387 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6388 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6389 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6390 }
6391 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6392 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6393 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006394 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006395 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006396
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006397 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006398 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6399 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6400 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6401 if (isSFINAEContext())
6402 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006403 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006404 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006405 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6406 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6407 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6408
6409 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6410 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6411 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6412 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6413 return QualType();
6414 }
6415 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6416 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6417
6418 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6419 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6420 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6421 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6422
6423 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6424 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6425 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6426 << op->getSourceRange();
6427 }
6428
6429 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6430 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6431 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006432 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006433 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006434 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006435 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006436 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6437 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006438 return QualType();
6439 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006440 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006441 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6442 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6443 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006444 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006445 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006446 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006447 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006448 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006449 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006450 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6451 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6452 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6453 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6454 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006455 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6456 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006457 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6458 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006459 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006460 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006461 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6462 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006463 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6464 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006465 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006466 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006467 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6468 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006469 return QualType();
6470 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006471 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006472 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006473 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006474 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006475 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6476 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006477 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006478 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006479 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6480 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006481 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006482 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6483 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6484 return QualType();
6485 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006486
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006487 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6488 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006489 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006490 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006491 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006492 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006493 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006494
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006495 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6496 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6497 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6498 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6499 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6500 }
6501
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006502 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006503 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6504 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006505 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6506}
6507
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006508/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006509QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006510 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6511 return Context.DependentTy;
6512
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006513 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006514 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6515 QualType Result;
6516
6517 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6518 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6519 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6520 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6521 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6522 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6523 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6524 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6525 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006526 else {
6527 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6528 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6529 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6530 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006531
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006532 if (Result.isNull()) {
6533 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6534 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6535 return QualType();
6536 }
6537
6538 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006539}
6540
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006541static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006542 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006543 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006544 switch (Kind) {
6545 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006546 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6547 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6548 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6549 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6550 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6551 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6552 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6553 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6554 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6555 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6556 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6557 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6558 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6559 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6560 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6561 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6562 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6563 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6564 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6565 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6566 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6567 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6568 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6569 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6570 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6571 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6572 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6573 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6574 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6575 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6576 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6577 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006578 }
6579 return Opc;
6580}
6581
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006582static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006583 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006584 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006585 switch (Kind) {
6586 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006587 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6588 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6589 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6590 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6591 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6592 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6593 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6594 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6595 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6596 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6597 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006598 }
6599 return Opc;
6600}
6601
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006602/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6603/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6604/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006605ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006606 unsigned Op,
6607 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006608 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006609 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006610 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6611 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6612 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006613
6614 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006615 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006616 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6617 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006618 case BO_PtrMemD:
6619 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006620 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006621 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006622 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006623 case BO_Mul:
6624 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006625 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006626 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006627 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006628 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006629 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6630 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006631 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006632 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6633 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006634 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006635 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6636 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006637 case BO_Shl:
6638 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006639 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6640 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006641 case BO_LE:
6642 case BO_LT:
6643 case BO_GE:
6644 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006645 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006646 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006647 case BO_EQ:
6648 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006649 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006650 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006651 case BO_And:
6652 case BO_Xor:
6653 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006654 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6655 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006656 case BO_LAnd:
6657 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006658 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006659 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006660 case BO_MulAssign:
6661 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006662 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006663 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006664 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6665 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6666 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006667 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006668 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006669 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6670 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6671 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6672 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006673 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006674 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006675 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6676 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6677 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006678 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006679 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006680 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6681 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6682 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006683 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006684 case BO_ShlAssign:
6685 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006686 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6687 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6688 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6689 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006690 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006691 case BO_AndAssign:
6692 case BO_XorAssign:
6693 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006694 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6695 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6696 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6697 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006698 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006699 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006700 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6701 break;
6702 }
6703 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006704 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006705 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006706 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006707 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6708 << ResultTy;
6709 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006710 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006711 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6712 else
6713 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006714 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6715 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006716}
6717
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006718/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6719/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006720static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6721 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006722 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6723 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6724 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006725 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006726 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6727
6728 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6729 return;
6730
6731 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6732 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6733 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006734 return;
6735 }
6736
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006737 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6738 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006739 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006740
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006741 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006742 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006743
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006744 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6745 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6746 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6747 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006748 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006749 return;
6750 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006751
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006752 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006753 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6754 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006755}
6756
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006757/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6758/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6759/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6760/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006761static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006762 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006763 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6764 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6765 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6766 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006767 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006768 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006769 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6770
6771 // Subs are not binary operators.
6772 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6773 return;
6774
6775 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6776 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006777 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6778 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006779 return;
6780
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006781 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006782 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006783 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006784 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6785 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006786 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006787 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006788 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6789 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6790 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6791 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006792 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006793 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006794 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006795 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6796 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006797 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006798 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006799 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6800 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6801 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6802 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006803}
6804
6805/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6806/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6807/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006808static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006809 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006810 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006811 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6812}
6813
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006814// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006815ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006816 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6817 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6818 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006819 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6820 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006821
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006822 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6823 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6824
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006825 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6826}
6827
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006828ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006829 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6830 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006831 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006832 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6833 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006834 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006835 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006836 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6837 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6838 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6839 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6840 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006841 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006842 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006843 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6844 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6845 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006846
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006847 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6848 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006849 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006850 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006851
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006852 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006853 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006854}
6855
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006856ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006857 unsigned OpcIn,
6858 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006859 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006860
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006861 QualType resultType;
6862 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006863 case UO_PreInc:
6864 case UO_PreDec:
6865 case UO_PostInc:
6866 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006867 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006868 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6869 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6870 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6871 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006872 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006873 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006874 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6875 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006876 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006877 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006878 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6879 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006880 case UO_Plus:
6881 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006882 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6883 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006884 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6885 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006886 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6887 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006888 break;
6889 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6890 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6891 break;
6892 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006893 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006894 resultType->isPointerType())
6895 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006896 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6897 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6898 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6899 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6900 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006901
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006902 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6903 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006904 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006905 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6906 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006907 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6908 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006909 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6910 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6911 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006912 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006913 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006914 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6915 break;
6916 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6917 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6918 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6919 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6920 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006921 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6922 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006923 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006924 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006925 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006926 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006927 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006928 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006929 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6930 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006931 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6932 // ok, fallthrough
6933 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6934 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6935 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6936 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6937 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006938 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6939 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006940 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006941
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006942 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006943 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6944 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006945 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006946 case UO_Real:
6947 case UO_Imag:
6948 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006949 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006950 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006951 resultType = Input->getType();
6952 break;
6953 }
6954 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006955 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006956
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006957 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006958}
6959
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006960ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006961 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6962 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006963 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006964 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006965 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6966 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6967 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6968 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006969 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006970 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006971 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6972 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6973 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006974
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006975 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006976 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006977
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006978 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006979}
6980
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006981// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006982ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006983 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6984 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006985}
6986
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006987/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006988ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006989 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6990 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006991 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006992 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006993
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006994 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6995 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006996 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006997 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006998
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00006999 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007000 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007001 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7002 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007003}
7004
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007005ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007006Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007007 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007008 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7009 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7010
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007011 bool isFileScope
7012 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007013 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007014 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007015
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007016 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7017 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7018 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007019
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007020 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7021 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7022 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007023
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007024 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7025 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
7026 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
7027 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
7028 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007029
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007030 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007031 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007032 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007033
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007034 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7035 // expressions are not lvalues.
7036
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007037 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007038}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007039
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007040ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007041 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7042 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7043 unsigned NumComponents,
7044 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007045 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007046 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007047 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007048
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007049 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7050 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7051 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007052 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007053 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7054 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7055
7056 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7057 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7058 if (!Dependent
7059 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7060 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7061 << TypeRange))
7062 return ExprError();
7063
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007064 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7065 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007066 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7067 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007068 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007069 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7070 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007071
7072 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7073 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7074 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7075 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7076 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7077 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7078 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7079 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7080 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7081 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7082 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7083 if(!AT)
7084 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7085 << CurrentType);
7086 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7087 } else
7088 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7089
7090 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7091 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7092 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7093 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7094 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7095 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7096 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7097 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7098
7099 // Record this array index.
7100 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7101 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7102 continue;
7103 }
7104
7105 // Offset of a field.
7106 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7107 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7108 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7109 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7110 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7111 continue;
7112 }
7113
7114 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7115 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7116 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7117 return ExprError();
7118
7119 // Look for the designated field.
7120 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7121 if (!RC)
7122 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7123 << CurrentType);
7124 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7125
7126 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7127 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7128 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7129 // (clause 9).
7130 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7131 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7132 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7133 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7134 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7135 << CurrentType))
7136 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7137 }
7138
7139 // Look for the field.
7140 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7141 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7142 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7143 if (!MemberDecl)
7144 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7145 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7146 OC.LocEnd));
7147
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007148 // C99 7.17p3:
7149 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7150 //
7151 // We diagnose this as an error.
7152 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7153 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7154 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7155 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7156 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7157 return ExprError();
7158 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007159
7160 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7161 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7162 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7163 do {
7164 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7165 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7166 }
7167
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007168 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7169 // the base class indirections.
7170 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7171 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007172 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007173 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7174 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7175 B != BEnd; ++B)
7176 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7177 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007178
7179 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007180 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7181 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7182 unsigned n = Path.size();
7183 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7184 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7185 } else {
7186 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7187 }
7188 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7189 }
7190
7191 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7192 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7193 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7194}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007195
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007196ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007197 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7198 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7199 ParsedType argty,
7200 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7201 unsigned NumComponents,
7202 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7203
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007204 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7205 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7206 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7207 return ExprError();
7208
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007209 if (!ArgTInfo)
7210 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7211
7212 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7213 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007214}
7215
7216
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007217ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007218 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7219 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007220 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7221 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7222 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7223 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007224
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007225 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007226
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007227 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7228}
7229
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007230ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007231Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7232 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7233 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7234 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007235 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7236 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7237 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7238 return ExprError();
7239 }
7240
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007241 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007242 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007243}
7244
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007245
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007246ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007247 Expr *CondExpr,
7248 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7249 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007250 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7251
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007252 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007253 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007254 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007255 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007256 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007257 } else {
7258 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7259 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7260 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7261 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007262 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7263 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7264 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007265
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007266 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7267 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007268 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7269 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007270 }
7271
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007272 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007273 resType, RPLoc,
7274 resType->isDependentType(),
7275 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007276}
7277
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007278//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7279// Clang Extensions.
7280//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7281
7282/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007283void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007284 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7285 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7286 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007287 if (BlockScope)
7288 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7289 else
7290 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007291}
7292
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007293void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007294 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007295 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007296
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007297 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007298 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007299 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007300
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007301 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007302 QualType RetTy;
7303 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007304 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007305 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007306 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007307 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7308 } else {
7309 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007310 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007311 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007312
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007313 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007314
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007315 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7316 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7317 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007318 return;
7319 }
7320
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007321 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7322 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7323 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7324 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7325 return;
7326 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007327
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007328 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007329 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7330 // ^ * { ... }
7331 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007332 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7333 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007334
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007335 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007336 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007337 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7338 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7339 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7340 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007341 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7342 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7343 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7344 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7345 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007346 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007347 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007348
7349 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7350 // ^ fntype { ... }
7351 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7352 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7353 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7354 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7355 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7356 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7357 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007358 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007359 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007360 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007361
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007362 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7363 if (!Params.empty())
7364 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007365
7366 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007367 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007368
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007369 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007370 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7371 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7372 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7373 }
7374
7375 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7376 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007377 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007378 return;
7379
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007380 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7381 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7382
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007383 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007384 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7385 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7386
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007387 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007388 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7389 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7390 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7391
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007392 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007393 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007394 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007395}
7396
7397/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7398/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7399void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007400 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007401 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007402 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007403 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007404}
7405
7406/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7407/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007408ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007409 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007410 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7411 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7412 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007413
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007414 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007415
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007416 PopDeclContext();
7417
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007418 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007419 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7420 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007421
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007422 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007423 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007424
7425 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7426 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7427 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7428
7429 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7430 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7431
7432 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7433 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7434 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7435 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7436
7437 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7438 // preserve its sugar structure.
7439 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7440 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7441 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7442
7443 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7444 } else {
7445 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7446 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7447 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7448 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7449 FPT->isVariadic(),
7450 /*quals*/ 0,
7451 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7452 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7453 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7454 FPT->exception_begin(),
7455 Ext);
7456 }
7457
7458 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7459 } else {
7460 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7461 false, false, 0, 0,
7462 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7463 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007464
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007465 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007466 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7467 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007468 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007469
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007470 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007471 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007472 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007473
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007474 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007475
7476 bool Good = true;
7477 // Check goto/label use.
7478 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7479 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7480 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7481
7482 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7483 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007484 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7485 if (!L->isUsed())
7486 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007487 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007488 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007489
7490 // Emit error.
7491 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7492 Good = false;
7493 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007494 if (!Good) {
7495 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007496 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007497 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007498
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007499 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7500 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7501
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007502 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007503 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7504 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007505 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007506
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007507 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007508 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007509}
7510
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007511ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007512 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007513 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007514 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7515 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007516 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007517}
7518
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007519ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007520 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007521 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007522 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007523
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007524 // Get the va_list type
7525 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007526 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7527 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7528 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7529 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007530 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007531 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7532 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7533 } else {
7534 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7535 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007536 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007537 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007538 return ExprError();
7539 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007540
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007541 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7542 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007543 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7544 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007545 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007546 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007547
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007548 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007549 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007550
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007551 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7552 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007553}
7554
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007555ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007556 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7557 // pointers on the target.
7558 QualType Ty;
7559 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7560 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7561 else
7562 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7563
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007564 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007565}
7566
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007567static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007568 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007569 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7570 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007571
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007572 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7573 if (!PT)
7574 return;
7575
7576 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7577 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7578 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7579 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7580 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7581 return;
7582 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007583
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007584 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7585 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7586 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7587 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007588
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007589 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007590}
7591
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007592bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7593 SourceLocation Loc,
7594 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007595 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7596 bool *Complained) {
7597 if (Complained)
7598 *Complained = false;
7599
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007600 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7601 bool isInvalid = false;
7602 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007603 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007604
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007605 switch (ConvTy) {
7606 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7607 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007608 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007609 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7610 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007611 case IntToPointer:
7612 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7613 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007614 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007615 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007616 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7617 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007618 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7619 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7620 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007621 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7622 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7623 break;
7624 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007625 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7626 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7627 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7628 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7629 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7630 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7631 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7632 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7633 // C++ semantics.
7634 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7635 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7636 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007637 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7638 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007639 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007640 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007641 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007642 case IntToBlockPointer:
7643 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7644 break;
7645 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007646 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007647 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007648 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007649 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007650 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7651 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7652 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007653 case IncompatibleVectors:
7654 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7655 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007656 case Incompatible:
7657 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7658 isInvalid = true;
7659 break;
7660 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007661
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007662 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7663 switch (Action) {
7664 case AA_Assigning:
7665 case AA_Initializing:
7666 // The destination type comes first.
7667 FirstType = DstType;
7668 SecondType = SrcType;
7669 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007670
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007671 case AA_Returning:
7672 case AA_Passing:
7673 case AA_Converting:
7674 case AA_Sending:
7675 case AA_Casting:
7676 // The source type comes first.
7677 FirstType = SrcType;
7678 SecondType = DstType;
7679 break;
7680 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007681
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007682 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007683 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007684 if (Complained)
7685 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007686 return isInvalid;
7687}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007688
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007689bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007690 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7691 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7692 if (Result)
7693 *Result = ICEResult;
7694 return false;
7695 }
7696
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007697 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7698
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007699 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007700 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7701 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7702
7703 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7704 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7705 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7706 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7707 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7708 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7709 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007710
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007711 return true;
7712 }
7713
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007714 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7715 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007716
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007717 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7718 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7719 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007720
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007721 if (Result)
7722 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7723 return false;
7724}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007725
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007726void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007727Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007728 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7729 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007730}
7731
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007732void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007733Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7734 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7735 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7736 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007737
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007738 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7739 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7740 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7741 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7742 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007743 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007744 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7745 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7746 I != IEnd; ++I)
7747 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7748 }
7749
7750 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7751 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7752 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7753 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7754 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7755 I != IEnd; ++I)
7756 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7757 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007758 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007759
7760 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7761 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7762 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7763 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007764 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007765 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7766 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7767 ExprTemporaries.end());
7768
7769 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7770 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007771}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007772
7773/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7774///
7775/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7776/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7777/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7778/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7779///
7780/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7781///
7782/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7783void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7784 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007785
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007786 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007787 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007788
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007789 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7790 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7791 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7792 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007793 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007794 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007795 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007796 return;
7797 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007798
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007799 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7800 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007801
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007802 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7803 // an instantiation.
7804 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7805 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007806
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007807 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007808 case Unevaluated:
7809 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7810 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007811
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007812 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7813 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7814 // "used"; handle this below.
7815 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007816
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007817 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7818 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7819 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7820 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007821 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007822 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007823
7824 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7825 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7826 // containing expression is used.
7827 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007828 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007829
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007830 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007831 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007832 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007833 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007834 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7835 return;
7836 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7837 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007838 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007839 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007840 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007841 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7842 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007843
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007844 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007845 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007846 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007847 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007848 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7849 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007850 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7851 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7852 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007853 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007854 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007855 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7856 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007857 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007858 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007859 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007860 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007861 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007862 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7863 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7864 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7865 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7866 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007867 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007868 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007869 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007870 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007871 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7872 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7873 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007874 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007875 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007876 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7877 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007878
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007879 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7880 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7881 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7882 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7883 Loc));
7884 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007885 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007886 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007887 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7888 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7889 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007890 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007891 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7892 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007893
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007894 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007895
7896 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7897 if (CurContext != Function)
7898 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007899
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007900 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007901 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007902
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007903 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007904 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007905 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007906 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7907 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7908 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7909 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7910 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7911 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007912 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007913 }
7914 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007915
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007916 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007917
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007918 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007919 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007920 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007921}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007922
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007923namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007924 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007925 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007926 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007927 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7928 Sema &S;
7929 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007930
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007931 public:
7932 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007933
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007934 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007935
7936 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7937 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007938 };
7939}
7940
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007941bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7942 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007943 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7944 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7945 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007946
7947 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007948}
7949
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007950bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007951 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7952 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7953 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007954 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7955 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007956 }
7957
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007958 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007959}
7960
7961void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7962 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007963 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007964}
7965
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007966namespace {
7967 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7968 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7969 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7970 Sema &S;
7971
7972 public:
7973 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7974
7975 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7976
7977 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7978 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7979 }
7980
7981 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7982 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007983 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007984 }
7985
7986 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7987 if (E->getConstructor())
7988 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7989 if (E->getOperatorNew())
7990 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
7991 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7992 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007993 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007994 }
7995
7996 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
7997 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7998 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00007999 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8000 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8001 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8002 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8003 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8004 }
8005
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008006 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008007 }
8008
8009 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8010 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008011 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008012 }
8013
8014 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8015 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8016 }
8017 };
8018}
8019
8020/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8021/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8022void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8023 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8024}
8025
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008026/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8027/// of the program being compiled.
8028///
8029/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008030/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008031/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8032/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8033/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8034/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008035/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008036/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008037///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008038/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8039/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8040/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8041/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008042bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008043 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8044 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8045 case Unevaluated:
8046 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8047 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008048
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008049 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008050 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008051 Diag(Loc, PD);
8052 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008053
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008054 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8055 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8056 break;
8057 }
8058
8059 return false;
8060}
8061
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008062bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8063 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8064 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8065 return false;
8066
8067 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8068 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8069 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8070 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008071
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008072 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008073 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008074 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8075 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008076 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008077 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8078 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8079 return true;
8080
8081 return false;
8082}
8083
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008084// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8085// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8086void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8087 SourceLocation Loc;
8088
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008089 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8090
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008091 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8092 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008093 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008094 return;
8095
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008096 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8097 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8098 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8099 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8100
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008101 // self = [<foo> init...]
8102 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8103 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8104 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8105
8106 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8107 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8108 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8109 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8110 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008111
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008112 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8113 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8114 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8115 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8116 return;
8117
8118 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8119 } else {
8120 // Not an assignment.
8121 return;
8122 }
8123
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008124 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008125 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008126
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008127 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008128 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008129 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008130 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8131 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8132 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008133}
8134
8135bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8136 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8137
8138 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008139 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008140
8141 QualType T = E->getType();
8142
8143 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8144 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8145 return true;
8146 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8147 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8148 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8149 return true;
8150 }
8151 }
8152
8153 return false;
8154}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008155
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008156ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8157 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008158 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008159 return ExprError();
8160
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008161 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008162 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008163
8164 return Owned(Sub);
8165}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008166
8167/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8168/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8169ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8170 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8171 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8172
8173 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8174 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8175 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8176 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8177 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8178 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8179 Specialization->getAccess());
8180 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8181 if (!E) return ExprError();
8182 return Owned(E);
8183 }
8184
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008185 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008186 return ExprError();
8187 }
8188
8189 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8190 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8191
8192 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8193 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8194 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8195 return ExprError();
8196}